blob: fa2b65b2deb2fa395f3c760e4150df42107ad022 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000062 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000478 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000479 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000480 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
481 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000483 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000484 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000485 << D->getIdentifier();
486 return ExprError();
487 }
488 }
489 }
490 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000491
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000492 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000493
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000494 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
495 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
496 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000497 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000498}
499
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000500/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
501/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
502/// actual member.
503///
504/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
505/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
506/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
507/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
508/// we found.
509///
510/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
511/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
512/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
513VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
514 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000515 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
516 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
517 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
518
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000519 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000520 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
521 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
522 do {
523 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000524 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000525 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000526 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 else {
528 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
529 break;
530 }
531 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000532 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534
535 return BaseObject;
536}
537
538Sema::OwningExprResult
539Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
540 FieldDecl *Field,
541 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
542 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
543 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000544 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545 AnonFields);
546
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000547 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
548 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
549 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
550 // found via name lookup.
551 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000552 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 if (BaseObject) {
554 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
555 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000680/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
681/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
682/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000684 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
685 return false;
686
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
688 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
689 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
690 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
691 if (!BaseRT) return false;
692
693 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
696 return false;
697 }
698
699 return true;
700}
701
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000702/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
703/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
704static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000707 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
708 if (!DC) return true;
709
710 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
711 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
712
713 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
714 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
715
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716 return false;
717}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
720/// the prospective base classes.
721static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
722 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
723 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000724 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 return false;
726
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000727 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000728 if (!RD) return false;
729 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
730
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
732 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
733 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
734 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
735 if (!BaseRT) return false;
736
737 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000738 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
739 return false;
740 }
741
742 return true;
743}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000744
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745enum IMAKind {
746 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
747 IMA_Static,
748
749 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
750 IMA_Mixed,
751
752 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
753 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
754 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
757 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
758 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
759
760 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
761 IMA_Instance,
762
763 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
764 IMA_Unresolved,
765
766 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
767 /// context is not an instance method.
768 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
769
770 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
771 /// non-class context.
772 IMA_AnonymousMember,
773
774 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
775 /// context is not an instance method.
776 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
777
778 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
779 /// class.
780 IMA_Error_Unrelated
781};
782
783/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
784/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
785/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
786/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
787/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
788/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
789static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
790 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000791 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000792
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000793 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000795 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
796 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797
798 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
799 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
800
801 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
802 bool hasNonInstance = false;
803 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
804 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000805 NamedDecl *D = *I;
806 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000807 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
808
809 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
810 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
811 // that's a special case.
812 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
813 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
814 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
815 }
816 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
817 }
818 else
819 hasNonInstance = true;
820 }
821
822 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
823 // member reference.
824 if (Classes.empty())
825 return IMA_Static;
826
827 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
828 // an implicit member reference.
829 if (isStaticContext)
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
831
832 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
833 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
834 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
835 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000836 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000837 Classes))
838 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
839
840 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
841}
842
843/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
844static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
845 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
846 const LookupResult &R) {
847 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
848 SourceRange Range(Loc);
849 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
850
851 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
852 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
853 if (MD->isStatic()) {
854 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
855 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
856 << Range << R.getLookupName();
857 return;
858 }
859 }
860
861 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
862 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
863 return;
864 }
865
866 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000867}
868
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
870///
871/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000872bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
873 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
875
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000876 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000877 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
879 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000882 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
883 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000884
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000885 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
886 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
887 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
888 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000889 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000890 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000891 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
892 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
893
894 if (!R.empty()) {
895 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
896 R.suppressDiagnostics();
897
898 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
899 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
900 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
901 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
902
903 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
904 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
905 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000906 if (isInstance) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000907 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000908 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000909
910 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
911 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
912 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
913 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
914 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
915 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(R.getNameLoc(),
916 DepThisType, false);
917 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
918 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
919 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
920 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
921 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
922 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
923 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL, Name,
924 R.getNameLoc(), &TList);
925 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
926 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000927 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000928 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000929
930 // Do we really want to note all of these?
931 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
932 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
933
934 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
935 return false;
936 }
937 }
938 }
939
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000940 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000941 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000942 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000943 if (!R.empty()) {
944 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
945 if (SS.isEmpty())
946 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
947 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
948 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
949 else
950 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
951 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
952 << SS.getRange()
953 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
954 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
955 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
956 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
957 << ND->getDeclName();
958
959 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
960 return false;
961 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000962
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000963 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
964 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
965 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
966 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
967 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
968 // to recover well anyway.
969 if (SS.isEmpty())
970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
971 else
972 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
973 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
974 << SS.getRange();
975
976 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
977 return true;
978 }
979 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000980 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000981 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000982 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000984 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000986 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
987 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000988 return true;
989 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000990 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000991 }
992
993 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
994 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
995 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
996 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
997 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
998 << SS.getRange();
999 return true;
1000 }
1001
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001002 // Give up, we can't recover.
1003 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1004 return true;
1005}
1006
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001007static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
1008 IdentifierInfo *II,
1009 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1010 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1011 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1012 if (!IDecl)
1013 return 0;
1014 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1015 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1016 return 0;
1017 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1018 if (!property)
1019 return 0;
1020 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1021 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1022 return 0;
1023 return property;
1024}
1025
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001026static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001027 IdentifierInfo *II,
1028 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1029 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1030 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1031 if (!IDecl)
1032 return 0;
1033 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001034 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1035 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001036 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1037 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1038 if (!property)
1039 return 0;
1040 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1041 DynamicImplSeen =
1042 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1043 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001044 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1045 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001046 NameLoc,
1047 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1048 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1049 (Expr *)0, true);
1050 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1051 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1052 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1053 return Ivar;
1054 }
1055 return 0;
1056}
1057
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001058Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001059 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001060 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1061 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1062 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1063 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1064 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1065
1066 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001067 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001068
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001069 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001070
1071 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1072 DeclarationName Name;
1073 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1074 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001075 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1076 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001077
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001078 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001079
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001080 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1081 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001082 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1083 // (note: handled after lookup)
1084 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1085 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1086 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001087 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1088 // names a dependent type.
1089 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1090 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001091 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1092 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1093 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001094 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001095 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 TemplateArgs);
1097 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001098 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001099 // Perform the required lookup.
1100 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1101 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001102 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1103 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1104 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1105 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1106 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001107 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1108 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1109 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001110 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001111 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001112 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001113
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001114 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1115 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001116 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1117 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001118 if (E.isInvalid())
1119 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001120
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001121 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1122 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001123 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1124 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001125 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001126 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1127 isAddressOfOperand);
1128 }
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001129 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001130 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001131
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001132 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1133 return ExprError();
1134
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001135 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1136 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001138
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001139 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001140 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1142 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1143 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1144 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1145 }
1146
1147 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1148 // call, diagnose the problem.
1149 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001150 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001151 return ExprError();
1152
1153 assert(!R.empty() &&
1154 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001155
1156 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1157 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001158 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001159 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1160 R.clear();
1161 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1162 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1163 return move(E);
1164 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001165 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001166 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001167
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1169 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1170
1171 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001172 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
1173 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
1174 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1175 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1176 if (Property) {
1177 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1178 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
1179 }
1180 }
1181
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001182 // Warn about constructs like:
1183 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1184 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001185 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1186 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001187 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001188 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001189 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001190 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001191 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001192 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1193 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001194 break;
1195 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001196
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001197 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1198 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001199 }
1200 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001201 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001202 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1203 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1204 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1205 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1206 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1207 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001209 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001210
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001211 QualType T = Func->getType();
1212 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001213 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001214 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1215 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001216 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001217 }
1218 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001219
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001220 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1221 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1222 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1223 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1224 // class member access expression.
1225 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1226 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001227 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001228 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001229 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1230 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001231 }
1232
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001233 if (TemplateArgs)
1234 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001235
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001236 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1237}
1238
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001239/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1240Sema::OwningExprResult
1241Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1242 LookupResult &R,
1243 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1244 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1245 case IMA_Instance:
1246 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1247
1248 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1249 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1250 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1251 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1252
1253 case IMA_Mixed:
1254 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1255 case IMA_Unresolved:
1256 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1257
1258 case IMA_Static:
1259 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1260 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1261 if (TemplateArgs)
1262 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1263 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1264
1265 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1266 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1267 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1268 return ExprError();
1269 }
1270
1271 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1272 return ExprError();
1273}
1274
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001275/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1276/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1277/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1278/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001279Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001280Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001281 DeclarationName Name,
1282 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1283 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001284 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001285 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1286
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001287 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001288 return ExprError();
1289
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001290 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1291 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1292
1293 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1294 return ExprError();
1295
1296 if (R.empty()) {
1297 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1298 return ExprError();
1299 }
1300
1301 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1302}
1303
1304/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1305/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1306/// additional lookup.
1307///
1308/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1309/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1310///
1311/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1312Sema::OwningExprResult
1313Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001314 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001315 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001316 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001317
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001318 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1319 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1320 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1321 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1322 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1323
1324 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1325 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1326 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001327 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001328
1329 bool LookForIvars;
1330 if (Lookup.empty())
1331 LookForIvars = true;
1332 else if (IsClassMethod)
1333 LookForIvars = false;
1334 else
1335 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1336 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001337 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001338 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001339 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001340 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1341 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1342 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1343 if (IsClassMethod)
1344 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1345 << IV->getDeclName());
1346
1347 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1348 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1349 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1350 return ExprError();
1351
1352 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1353 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1354 return ExprError();
1355
1356 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1357 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1358 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1359 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1360
1361 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1362 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1363 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1364 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001365 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001366 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1367 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1368 SelfName, false, false);
1369 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1370 return Owned(new (Context)
1371 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1372 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1373 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001374 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001376 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001377 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1378 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1379 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1380 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1381 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1382 }
1383 }
1384
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001385 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1386 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1387 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1388 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1389 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1390 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1391 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1392 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1393 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1394 }
1395 }
1396 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001397 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1398 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001399}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001400
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001401/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1402///
1403/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1404///
1405/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1406/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1407/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1408/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1409///
1410/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1411/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1412/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1413/// the class declaring the member.
1414///
1415/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1416/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1417/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001418bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001419Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1420 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001421 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001422 NamedDecl *Member) {
1423 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1424 if (!RD)
1425 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001426
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001427 QualType DestRecordType;
1428 QualType DestType;
1429 QualType FromRecordType;
1430 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1431 bool PointerConversions = false;
1432 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1433 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001434
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001435 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1436 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1437 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1438 PointerConversions = true;
1439 } else {
1440 DestType = DestRecordType;
1441 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001442 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001443 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1444 if (Method->isStatic())
1445 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001446
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001447 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1448 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001449
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001450 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1451 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1452 PointerConversions = true;
1453 } else {
1454 FromRecordType = FromType;
1455 DestType = DestRecordType;
1456 }
1457 } else {
1458 // No conversion necessary.
1459 return false;
1460 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001461
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001462 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1463 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001464
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001465 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1466 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1467 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001468
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001469 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1470 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1471
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001472 ImplicitCastExpr::ResultCategory Category = CastCategory(From);
1473
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001474 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001475 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001476 // class name.
1477 //
1478 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1479 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1480 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1481 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1482 //
1483 // class Base { public: int x; };
1484 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1485 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1486 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1487 //
1488 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1489 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1490 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1491 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001493 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1494 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1495 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1496
1497 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1498
1499 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1500 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1501 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1502 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001503 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001504 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001505 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001506 return true;
1507
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001508 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001509 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001510 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001511 Category, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001512
1513 FromType = QType;
1514 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1515
1516 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1517 // we're done.
1518 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1519 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001520 }
1521 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001522
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001523 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001524
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001525 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1526 // down to the using declaration's type.
1527 //
1528 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1529 // class ever has member declarations.
1530 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1531 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1532 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1533 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1534
1535 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1536 // conversion is non-trivial.
1537 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1538 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001539 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001540 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001541 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001542 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001543
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001544 QualType UType = URecordType;
1545 if (PointerConversions)
1546 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001547 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001548 Category, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001549 FromType = UType;
1550 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1551 }
1552
1553 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1554 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1555 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001556 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001557
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001558 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1559 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1560 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001561 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001563
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001564 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001565 Category, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001566 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001567}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001568
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001569/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001570static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001571 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001572 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1573 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001574 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1575 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1576 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001577 if (SS.isSet()) {
1578 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1579 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001580 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001581
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001582 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001583 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001584}
1585
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001586/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1587/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1588/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1589/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001590Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001591Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1592 LookupResult &R,
1593 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1594 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001595 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1596
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001597 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001598
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001599 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1600 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001601 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001602 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001603 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001604 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001605 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001606
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001607 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1608 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001609 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1610 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001611 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1612 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001613 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1614 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1615 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1616 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001617 }
1618
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001619 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1620 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1621 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001622 SS,
1623 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1624 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001625}
1626
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001627bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001628 const LookupResult &R,
1629 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001630 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1631 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1632 return false;
1633
1634 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001635 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001636 return false;
1637
1638 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001639 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001640 return false;
1641
1642 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1643 // normal lookup:
1644 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1645 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1646
1647 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1648 // -- a declaration of a class member
1649 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1650 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001651 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001652 return false;
1653
1654 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1655 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1656 // using-declaration
1657 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1658 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1659 // turn off ADL anyway).
1660 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1661 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1662 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1663 return false;
1664
1665 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1666 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1667 // template
1668 // And also for builtin functions.
1669 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1670 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1671
1672 // But also builtin functions.
1673 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1674 return false;
1675 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1676 return false;
1677 }
1678
1679 return true;
1680}
1681
1682
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001683/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1684/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1685/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1686/// will in fact be used.
1687static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1688 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1689 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1690 return true;
1691 }
1692
1693 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1694 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1695 return true;
1696 }
1697
1698 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1699 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1700 return true;
1701 }
1702
1703 return false;
1704}
1705
1706Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001707Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001708 LookupResult &R,
1709 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001710 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1711 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001712 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001713 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001714
1715 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1716 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1717 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001718 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1719 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001720 return ExprError();
1721
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001722 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1723 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1724 // we've picked a target.
1725 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1726
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001727 bool Dependent
1728 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001729 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001730 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001731 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1732 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001733 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001734 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1735 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001736
1737 return Owned(ULE);
1738}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001739
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001740
1741/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1742Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001743Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001744 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1745 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001746 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1747 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001748
1749 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1750 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001751
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001752 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1753 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1754 // a template argument list.
1755 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1756 << Template << SS.getRange();
1757 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1758 return ExprError();
1759 }
1760
1761 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1762 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1763 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001764 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001765 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001766 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001767 return ExprError();
1768 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001769
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001770 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1771 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1772 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1773 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001774 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001775 return ExprError();
1776
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001777 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1778 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001779 return ExprError();
1780
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001781 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1782 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1783 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1784 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001785 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001786 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1787 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1788 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001789 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001790 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001791 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1792 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1793 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1794 return ExprError();
1795 }
1796
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001797 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001798 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1799 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1800 return ExprError();
1801 }
1802
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001803 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001804 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001805 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001806 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001807 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001808 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1809 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001810 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001811
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001812 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001813 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001814 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1815 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001816 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001817 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1818 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1819 Expr *E = new (Context)
1820 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1821 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001822
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001823 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
1824 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001825 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001826 SourceLocation(),
1827 Owned(E));
1828 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1829 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
1830 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1831 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1832 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001833 }
1834 }
1835 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001836 }
1837 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1838 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001839
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001840 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001841}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001842
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001843Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1844 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001845 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001846
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001847 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001848 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001849 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1850 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1851 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001852 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001853
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001854 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1855 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001856
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001857 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001858 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1859 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001860 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001861 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001862 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001863 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001864
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001865 QualType ResTy;
1866 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1867 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1868 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001869 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001870
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001871 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001872 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001873 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1874 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001875 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001876}
1877
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001878Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001879 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001880 bool Invalid = false;
1881 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1882 if (Invalid)
1883 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001884
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001885 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1886 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001887 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001888 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001889
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001890 QualType Ty;
1891 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1892 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1893 else if (Literal.isWide())
1894 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001895 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1896 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001897 else
1898 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001899
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001900 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1901 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001902 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001903}
1904
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001905Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1906 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001907 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1908 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001909 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001910 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001911 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001912 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001913 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001914
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001915 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001916 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1917 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001918 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001919
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001920 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001921 bool Invalid = false;
1922 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1923 if (Invalid)
1924 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001925
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001926 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001927 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001928 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001929 return ExprError();
1930
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001931 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001932
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001933 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001934 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001935 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001936 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001937 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001938 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001939 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001940 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001941
1942 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1943
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001944 using llvm::APFloat;
1945 APFloat Val(Format);
1946
1947 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001948
1949 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1950 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1951 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1952 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001953 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001954 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001955 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001956 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001957 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1958 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001959 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001960 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1961 }
1962
1963 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1964 << Ty
1965 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1966 }
1967
1968 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001969 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001970
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001971 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001972 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001973 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001974 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001975
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001976 // long long is a C99 feature.
1977 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001978 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001979 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1980
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001981 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001982 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001983
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001984 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1985 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1986 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001987 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1988 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001989 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001990 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001991 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1992 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001993
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001994 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1995 // be an unsigned int.
1996 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1997
1998 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001999 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002000 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2001 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002002 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002003
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002004 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2005 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2006 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2007 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002008 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002009 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002010 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002011 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002012 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002013 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002014
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002015 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002016 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002017 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002018
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002019 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2020 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2021 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2022 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002023 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002024 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002025 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002026 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002027 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002028 }
2029
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002030 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002031 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002032 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002033
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002034 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2035 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2036 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2037 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002038 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002039 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002040 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002041 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002042 }
2043 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002044
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002045 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2046 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002047 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002048 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002049 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002050 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002051 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002052
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002053 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2054 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002055 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002056 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002057 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002058
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002059 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2060 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002061 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002062 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002063
2064 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002065}
2066
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002067Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2068 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002069 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002070 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002071 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002072}
2073
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002074/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002075/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002076bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002077 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2078 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2079 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002080 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2081 return false;
2082
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002083 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2084 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2085 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2086 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2087 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2088 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2089
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002090 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002091 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002092 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002093 if (isSizeof)
2094 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2095 return false;
2096 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002097
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002098 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002099 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002100 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2101 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002102 return false;
2103 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002104
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002105 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002106 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2107 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002108 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002109
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002110 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002111 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002112 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002113 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2114 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002115 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002116
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002117 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2118 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2119 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2120 return true;
2121 }
2122
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002123 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002124}
2125
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002126bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2127 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2128 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002129
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002130 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002131 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2132 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002133
2134 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2135 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2136 return false;
2137
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002138 if (E->getBitField()) {
2139 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2140 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002141 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002142
2143 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2144 // bit-field.
2145 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002146 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002147 return false;
2148
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002149 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2150}
2151
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002152/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002153Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002154Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002155 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002156 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002157 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002158 return ExprError();
2159
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002160 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002161
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002162 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2163 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2164 return ExprError();
2165
2166 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002167 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002168 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2169 R.getEnd()));
2170}
2171
2172/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2173/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002174Action::OwningExprResult
2175Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002176 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2177 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2178 bool isInvalid = false;
2179 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2180 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2181 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2182 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002183 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002184 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2185 isInvalid = true;
2186 } else {
2187 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2188 }
2189
2190 if (isInvalid)
2191 return ExprError();
2192
2193 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2194 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2195 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2196 R.getEnd()));
2197}
2198
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002199/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2200/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2201/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002202Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002203Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2204 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002205 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002206 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002207
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002208 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002209 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2210 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2211 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002212 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002213
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002214 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2215 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2216 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2217
2218 if (Result.isInvalid())
2219 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2220
2221 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002222}
2223
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002224QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002225 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2226 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002227
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002228 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002229 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002230 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002231
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002232 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2233 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2234 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002235
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002236 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002237 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2238 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002239 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002240}
2241
2242
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002243
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002244Action::OwningExprResult
2245Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2246 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002247 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2248 switch (Kind) {
2249 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2250 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2251 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2252 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002253
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002254 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002255}
2256
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002257Action::OwningExprResult
2258Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2259 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002260 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2261 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2262
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002263 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2264 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002265
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002266 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002267 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2268 Base.release();
2269 Idx.release();
2270 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2271 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2272 }
2273
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002274 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002275 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002276 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2277 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2278 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002279 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002280 }
2281
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002282 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2283}
2284
2285
2286Action::OwningExprResult
2287Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2288 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2289 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2290 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2291
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002292 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002293 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2294 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2295 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002296
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002297 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002298
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002299 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002300 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002301 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002302 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002303 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2304 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002305 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2306 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2307 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2308 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002309 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002310 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2311 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002312 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002313 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002314 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002315 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2316 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002317 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002318 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002319 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002320 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2321 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2322 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002323 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002324 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002325 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2326 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2327 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2328 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002329 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002330 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002331 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002332
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002333 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2334 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002335 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2336 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002337 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002338 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2339 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2340 // force the promotion here.
2341 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2342 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002343 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2344 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002345 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2346
2347 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2348 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002349 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002350 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2351 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2352 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2353 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002354 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2355 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002356 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2357
2358 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2359 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002360 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002361 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002362 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2363 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002364 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002365 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002366 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002367 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2368 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002369
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002370 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002371 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2372 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002373 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2374
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002375 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002376 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2377 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002378 // incomplete types are not object types.
2379 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2380 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2381 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2382 return ExprError();
2383 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002384
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002385 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002386 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002387 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2388 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002389 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002390
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002391 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002392 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002393 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2394 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2395 return ExprError();
2396 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002397
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002398 Base.release();
2399 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002400 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002401 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002402}
2403
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002404QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002405CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002406 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002407 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002408 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2409 // see FIXME there.
2410 //
2411 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2412 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002413 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002414
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002415 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002416 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002417
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002418 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002419 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2420 // to be selected.
2421 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002422
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002423 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2424 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002425 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002426
2427 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2428 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002429 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002430 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2431 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002432 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002433 do
2434 compStr++;
2435 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002436 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002437 do
2438 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002439 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002440 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002441
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002442 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002443 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2444 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002445 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2446 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002447 return QualType();
2448 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002449
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002450 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2451 // operates on.
2452 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002453 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002454
2455 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002456 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002457
2458 while (*compStr) {
2459 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2460 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2461 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2462 return QualType();
2463 }
2464 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002465 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002466
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002467 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002468 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002469 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002470 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002471 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002472 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002473 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002474 if (HexSwizzle)
2475 CompSize--;
2476
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002477 if (CompSize == 1)
2478 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002479
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002480 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002481 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002482 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2483 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2484 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2485 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002486 }
2487 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002488}
2489
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002490static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002491 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002492 const Selector &Sel,
2493 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002494
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002495 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002496 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002497 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002498 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002499
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002500 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2501 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002502 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002503 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002504 return D;
2505 }
2506 return 0;
2507}
2508
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002509static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002510 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002511 const Selector &Sel,
2512 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002513 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2514 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002515 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002516 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002517 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002518 GDecl = PD;
2519 break;
2520 }
2521 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002522 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002523 GDecl = OMD;
2524 break;
2525 }
2526 }
2527 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002528 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002529 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2530 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002531 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002532 if (GDecl)
2533 return GDecl;
2534 }
2535 }
2536 return GDecl;
2537}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002538
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002539Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002540Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2541 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002542 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2543 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2544 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2545 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2546 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2547
2548 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2549 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2550 //
2551 // T* t;
2552 // t.f;
2553 //
2554 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2555 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2556 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2557 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002558 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002559 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2560 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002561 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002562 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002563 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002564 return ExprError();
2565 }
2566 }
2567
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002568 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002569 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002570
2571 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2572 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002573 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002574 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2575 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2576 SS.getRange(),
2577 FirstQualifierInScope,
2578 Name, NameLoc,
2579 TemplateArgs));
2580}
2581
2582/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2583/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2584/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2585static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2586 Expr *BaseExpr,
2587 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002588 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002589 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002590 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2591 // diagnostics.
2592 if (!BaseExpr)
2593 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002594
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002595 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2596 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002597}
2598
2599// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2600// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2601// type. The restriction here is:
2602//
2603// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2604// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2605// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2606//
2607// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2608// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2609// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2610// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2611bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2612 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002613 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002614 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002615 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2616 if (!BaseRT) {
2617 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2618 // dependent.
2619 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2620 return false;
2621 }
2622 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002623
2624 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002625 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2626 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002627 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002628 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002629
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002630 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002631 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2632 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2633 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002634
2635 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002636 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002637
2638 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2639 return false;
2640 }
2641
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002642 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002643 return true;
2644}
2645
2646static bool
2647LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2648 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002649 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2650 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002651 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2652 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002653 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002654 << BaseRange))
2655 return true;
2656
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002657 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2658 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2659 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2660
2661 bool MOUS;
2662 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2663 return false;
2664 }
2665
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002666 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2667 if (SS.isSet()) {
2668 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2669 // nested-name-specifier.
2670 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2671
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002672 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002673 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2674 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2675 return true;
2676 }
2677
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002678 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002679
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002680 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2681 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2682 << DC << SS.getRange();
2683 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002684 }
2685 }
2686
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002687 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2688 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002689
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002690 if (!R.empty())
2691 return false;
2692
2693 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2694 // for typos.
2695 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002696 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002697 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002698 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2699 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2700 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002701 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2702 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002703 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2704 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2705 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002706 return false;
2707 } else {
2708 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002709 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002710 }
2711
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002712 return false;
2713}
2714
2715Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002716Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002717 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002718 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002719 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2720 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2721 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2722 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2723
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002724 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2725 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002726 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002727 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2728 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2729 Name, NameLoc,
2730 TemplateArgs);
2731
2732 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002733
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002734 // Implicit member accesses.
2735 if (!Base) {
2736 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2737 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2738 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2739 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002740 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002741 return ExprError();
2742
2743 // Explicit member accesses.
2744 } else {
2745 OwningExprResult Result =
2746 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002747 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002748
2749 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2750 Owned(Base);
2751 return ExprError();
2752 }
2753
2754 if (Result.get())
2755 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002756
2757 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2758 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002759 }
2760
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002761 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002762 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2763 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002764}
2765
2766Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002767Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2768 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2769 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002770 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002771 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002772 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2773 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002774 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002775 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002776 if (IsArrow) {
2777 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2778 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2779 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002780 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002781
2782 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2783 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2784 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2785 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2786
2787 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002788 return ExprError();
2789
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002790 if (R.empty()) {
2791 // Rederive where we looked up.
2792 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2793 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2794 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002795
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002796 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002797 << MemberName << DC
2798 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002799 return ExprError();
2800 }
2801
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002802 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2803 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2804 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2805 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2806 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2807 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2808 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2809 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2810 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2811 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002812 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002813 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002814 return ExprError();
2815
2816 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2817 // result.
2818 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002819 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002820 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002821 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002822 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002823
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002824 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2825 // pick a member.
2826 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2827
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002828 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2829 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2830 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002831 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2832 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002833 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2834 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002835 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836
2837 return Owned(MemExpr);
2838 }
2839
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002840 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002841 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002842 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2843
2844 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2845
2846 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2847 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2848 // error cases.
2849 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2850 return ExprError();
2851
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002852 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2853 if (!BaseExpr) {
2854 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002855 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002856 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2857
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002858 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2859 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2860 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2861 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002862 }
2863
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002864 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2865 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2866 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2867 // explicitly qualified.
2868 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2869 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2870 }
2871
2872 // Check the use of this member.
2873 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2874 Owned(BaseExpr);
2875 return ExprError();
2876 }
2877
2878 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2879 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2880 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002881 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2882 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002883 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2884 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2885
2886 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2887 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2888 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2889 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2890 else {
2891 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2892 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2893 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2894
2895 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2896 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2897
2898 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2899 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2900 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2901 }
2902
2903 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002904 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 return ExprError();
2906 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002907 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002908 }
2909
2910 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2911 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2912 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002913 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002914 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2915 }
2916
2917 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2918 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2919 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002920 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002921 MemberFn->getType()));
2922 }
2923
2924 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2925 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2926 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002927 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002928 }
2929
2930 Owned(BaseExpr);
2931
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002932 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002933 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002934 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2935 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2936 else
2937 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2938 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002939
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002940 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2941 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002942 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002943 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002944}
2945
2946/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2947/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2948/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2949/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2950/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2951/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2952/// an ordinary member expression.
2953///
2954/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2955/// fixed for ObjC++.
2956Sema::OwningExprResult
2957Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002958 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002959 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002960 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002961 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002962
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002963 // Perform default conversions.
2964 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002965
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002966 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002967 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2968
2969 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2970 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002971
2972 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002973 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002974 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2975 // call, and continue on.
2976 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2977 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2978 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2979 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2980 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2982 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002983 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2984 ->isRecordType()))) {
2985 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2986 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2987 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002988 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002989
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002990 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002991 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002992 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002993 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002994 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002995 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002996
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002997 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2998 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2999 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3000 }
3001 }
3002 }
3003
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003004 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3005 // use that.
3006 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003007 if (IsArrow) {
3008 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3009 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3010 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003011 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003012 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003013 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3014 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003015 }
3016 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003017 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3018 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3019 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3020 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003021 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003022 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003023 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003024
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003025 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3026 // use that.
3027 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3028 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3029 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3030 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3031 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
3032 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
3033 }
3034 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003035
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003036 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003037
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003038 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003039 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003040 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3041 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3042 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3043 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3044 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3045 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3046 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3047 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3048 // Check the use of this method.
3049 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3050 return ExprError();
3051 }
3052 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3053 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3054 Selector SetterSel =
3055 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3056 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3057 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3058 if (!Setter) {
3059 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3060 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003061 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003062 }
3063 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3064 if (!Setter)
3065 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003066
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003067 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3068 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003069
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003070 if (Getter || Setter) {
3071 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003072
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003073 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003074 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003075 else
3076 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3077 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3078 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003079 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003080 PType,
3081 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3082 }
3083 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3084 << MemberName << BaseType);
3085 }
3086 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003087
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003088 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3089 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3090 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003091 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003092 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003093
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003094 if (IsArrow) {
3095 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003096 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003097 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3098 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003099 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3100 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3101 // struct MyRecord foo;
3102 // foo->bar
3103 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3104 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3105 // by now.
3106 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3107 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003108 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003109 IsArrow = false;
3110 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003111 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3112 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3113 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003114 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003115 } else {
3116 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3117 // type *foo;
3118 // foo.bar
3119 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3120 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3121 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3122 // the appropriate pointer type
3123 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3124 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3125 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3126 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3127 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003128 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003129 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3130 IsArrow = true;
3131 }
3132 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003133 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003134
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003135 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003136 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003137 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003138 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003139 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003140 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003141 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003142
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003143 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3144 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003145 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003146 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003147 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003148 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3149 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3150 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3151 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003152 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3153
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003154 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003155 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003156
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003157 if (!IV) {
3158 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3159 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3160 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003161 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003162 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003163 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003164 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3165 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003166 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3167 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003168 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003169 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003170 } else {
3171 Res.clear();
3172 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003173 }
3174 }
3175
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003176 if (IV) {
3177 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3178 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3179 // error cases.
3180 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3181 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003182
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003183 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3184 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3185 return ExprError();
3186 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3187 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3188 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3189 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3190 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3191 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3192 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3193 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3194 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3195 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3196 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3197 // AST for a function decl.
3198 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003199 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003200 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3201 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3202 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3203 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3204 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3205 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003206
3207 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3208 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003209 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003210 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003211 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003212 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3213 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003214 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003215 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003216 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003217
3218 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3219 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003220 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003221 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003222 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003223 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003224 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003225 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003226 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003227 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003228 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3229 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003230 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003231 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003232
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003233 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003234 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003235 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3236 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3237 // Check the use of this declaration
3238 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3239 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003240
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003241 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3242 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3243 }
3244 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3245 // Check the use of this method.
3246 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3247 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003248
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003249 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003250 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003251 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3252 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003253 }
3254 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003255
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003256 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003257 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003258 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003259
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003260 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3261 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003262 if (!IsArrow)
3263 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3264 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003265 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003266
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003267 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003268 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003269 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3270 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003271 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003272 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003273 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003274
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003275 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003276 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003277 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003278 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3279 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003280 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003281 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003282 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003283 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003284
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003285 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3286 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3287
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003288 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003289}
3290
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003291/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3292/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3293/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3294/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3295/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3296///
3297/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3298/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3299/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3300/// only be called
3301/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3302/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3303/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3304Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3305 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3306 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003307 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003308 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3309 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3310 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3311 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3312 return ExprError();
3313
3314 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3315
3316 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3317 DeclarationName Name;
3318 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3319 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3320 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3321 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3322
3323 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3324
3325 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3326 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3327 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3328
3329 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3330 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3331
3332 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3333 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003334 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3335 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003336 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003337 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3338 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3339 Name, NameLoc,
3340 TemplateArgs);
3341 } else {
3342 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003343 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3344 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003345
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003346 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3347 Owned(Base);
3348 return ExprError();
3349 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003350
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003351 if (Result.get()) {
3352 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3353 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3354 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3355 // call now.
3356 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3357 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3358 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003359
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003360 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003361 }
3362
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003363 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003364 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3365 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003366 }
3367
3368 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003369}
3370
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003371Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3372 FunctionDecl *FD,
3373 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3374 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3375 Diag (CallLoc,
3376 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3377 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003378 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003379 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3380 } else {
3381 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3382 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3383
3384 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003385 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3386 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003387
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003388 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3389 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3390 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3391 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003392
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003393 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003394 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003395 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003396
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003397 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3398 InitializedEntity Entity
3399 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3400 InitializationKind Kind
3401 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3402 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3403 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3404
3405 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003406 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003407 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3408 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003409 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003410
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003411 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003412 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003413 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003414 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003415
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003416 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3417 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3418 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003419 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3420 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003421 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3422 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003423 }
3424
3425 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003426 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003427}
3428
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003429/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3430/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3431/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3432/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3433/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3434/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003435bool
3436Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003437 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003438 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003439 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3440 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003441 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003442 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3443 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003444 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003445
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003446 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3447 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3448 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3449 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3450 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003451 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003452 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003453 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003454 }
3455
3456 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3457 // them.
3458 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3459 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3460 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3461 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003462 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003463 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003464 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3465 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3466 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003467 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003468 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003469 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003470 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003471 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003472 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003473 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3474 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3475 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3476 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3477 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003478 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003479 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003480 if (Invalid)
3481 return true;
3482 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3483 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3484 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003485
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003486 return false;
3487}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003488
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003489bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3490 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3491 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3492 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3493 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3494 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003495 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003496 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3497 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3498 bool Invalid = false;
3499 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3500 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3501 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3502 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003503 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003504 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003505 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003506
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003507 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003508 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3509 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003510
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003511 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3512 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003513 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003514 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003515 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003516
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003517 // Pass the argument
3518 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3519 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3520 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003521
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003522
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003523 InitializedEntity Entity =
3524 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3525 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3526 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3527 SourceLocation(),
3528 Owned(Arg));
3529 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3530 return true;
3531
3532 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003533 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003534 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003535
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003536 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003537 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003538 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3539 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003540
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003541 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003542 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003543 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003544 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003545
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003546 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003547 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003548 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003549 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003550 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003551 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003552 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003553 }
3554 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003555 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003556}
3557
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003558/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003559/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3560/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003561Action::OwningExprResult
3562Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3563 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003564 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003565 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003566
3567 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3568 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003569
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003570 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003571 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003572 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003573
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003574 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003575 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3576 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3577 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3578 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3579 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003580 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003581 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3582 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003583
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003584 NumArgs = 0;
3585 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003586
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003587 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3588 RParenLoc));
3589 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003590
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003591 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003592 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003593 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3594 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003595 bool Dependent = false;
3596 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3597 Dependent = true;
3598 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3599 Dependent = true;
3600
3601 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003602 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003603 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3604
3605 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3606 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3607 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3608 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3609
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003610 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3611
3612 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3613 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3614 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3615 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3616 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3617 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3618 // method template.
3619 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003620 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3621 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003622 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003623
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003624 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3625 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003626 }
3627
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003628 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003629 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003630 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003631 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003632 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3633 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003634 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003635
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003636 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003637 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003638 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3639 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003640 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3641 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003642 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003643
3644 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3645 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003646 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3647 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003648
3649 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3650 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003651 TheCall.get(), 0))
3652 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003653
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003654 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003655 RParenLoc))
3656 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003657
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003658 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3659 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003660 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003661 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3662 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003663 }
3664 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003665 }
3666
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003667 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003668 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003669 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003670
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003671 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003672 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3673 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003674 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003675 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003676 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003677
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003678 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3679 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3680 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3681
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003682 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3683}
3684
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003685/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3686/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003687/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3688/// block-pointer type.
3689///
3690/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3691Sema::OwningExprResult
3692Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3693 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3694 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3695 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3696 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3697
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003698 // Promote the function operand.
3699 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3700
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003701 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3702 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003703 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3704 Args, NumArgs,
3705 Context.BoolTy,
3706 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003707
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003708 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3709 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3710 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3711 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003712 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003713 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003714 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3715 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003716 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003717 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003718 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003719 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003720 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003721 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003722 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3723 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3724
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003725 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003726 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003727 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3728 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003729 return ExprError();
3730
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003731 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003732 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003733
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003734 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003735 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003736 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003737 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003738 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003739 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003740
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003741 if (FDecl) {
3742 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3743 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3744 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003745 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003746 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003747 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003748 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3749 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3750 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3751 }
3752 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003753 }
3754
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003755 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003756 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3757 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3758 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003759 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3760 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003761 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3762 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003763 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003764 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003765 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003766 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003767
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003768 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3769 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003770 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3771 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003772
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003773 // Check for sentinels
3774 if (NDecl)
3775 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003776
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003777 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003778 if (FDecl) {
3779 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3780 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003781
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003782 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003783 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3784 } else if (NDecl) {
3785 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3786 return ExprError();
3787 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003788
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003789 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003790}
3791
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003792Action::OwningExprResult
3793Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3794 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003795 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003796 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003797 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003798
3799 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3800 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3801 if (!TInfo)
3802 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3803
3804 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3805}
3806
3807Action::OwningExprResult
3808Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3809 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3810 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003811 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003812
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003813 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003814 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003815 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3816 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003817 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3818 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003819 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003820 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003821 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003822 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003823
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003824 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003825 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003826 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003827 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003828 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003829 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3830 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3831 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3832 &literalType);
3833 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003834 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003835 InitExpr.release();
3836 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003837
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003838 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003839 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003840 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003841 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003842 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003843
3844 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003845
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003846 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003847 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003848}
3849
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003850Action::OwningExprResult
3851Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003852 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3853 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3854 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003855
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003856 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003857 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003858
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003859 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3860 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003861 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003862 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003863}
3864
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003865static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3866 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003867 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003868 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3869
3870 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3871 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003872 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3873 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003874 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003875 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3876 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3877 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003878
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003879 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3880 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3881 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3882 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3883 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3884 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3885 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3886 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003887
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003888 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3889 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3890 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3891 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3892 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3893 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003894
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003895 // FIXME: Assert here.
3896 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3897 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3898}
3899
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003900/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003901bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003902 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003903 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003904 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003905 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003906 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3907 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003908
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003909 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003910
3911 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3912 // type needs to be scalar.
3913 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3914 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003915 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3916 return false;
3917 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003918
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003919 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3920 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3921 return true;
3922
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003923 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003924 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003925 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3926 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003927 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003928 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3929 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003930 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003931 return false;
3932 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003933
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003934 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003935 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003936 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003937 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003938 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003939 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003940 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003941 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003942 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3943 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3944 break;
3945 }
3946 }
3947 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3948 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3949 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003950 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003951 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003952 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003953
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003954 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3955 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3956 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3957 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003958
3959 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003960 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003961 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3962 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003963 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003964 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003965
3966 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003967 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003968
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003969 if (castType->isVectorType())
3970 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3971 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3972 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3973
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003974 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3975 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003976
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003977 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003978 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003979 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003980 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003981 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3982 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3983 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3984 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003985 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003986 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3987 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3988 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003989 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003990
3991 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003992 return false;
3993}
3994
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003995bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3996 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003997 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003998
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003999 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004000 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004001 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004002 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004003 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004004 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004005 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004006 } else
4007 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004008 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004009 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004010
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004011 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004012 return false;
4013}
4014
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004015bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004016 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004017 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004018
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004019 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004020
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004021 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4022 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004023 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4024 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4025 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4026 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004027 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004028 return false;
4029 }
4030
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004031 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004032 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4033 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004034 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4035 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4036 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4037 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004038
4039 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4040 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4041 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004042
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004043 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004044 return false;
4045}
4046
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004047Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004048Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004049 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4050 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4051 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004052
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004053 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4054 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4055 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004056 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004057
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004058 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004059 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004060 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004061 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4062 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004063
4064 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4065}
4066
4067Action::OwningExprResult
4068Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4069 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4070 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4071
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004072 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004073 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004074 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004075 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004076 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004077
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004078 Op.release();
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004079 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(
4080 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004081 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004082 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004083}
4084
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004085/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4086/// of comma binary operators.
4087Action::OwningExprResult
4088Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4089 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4090 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4091 if (!E)
4092 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004093
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004094 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004095
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004096 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4097 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4098 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004100 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4101}
4102
4103Action::OwningExprResult
4104Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4105 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004106 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004107 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004108 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004109 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004110
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004111 // Check for an altivec literal,
4112 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004113 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4114 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4115 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4116 return ExprError();
4117 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004118 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4119 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4120 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4121 }
4122 else
4123 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4124 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004125
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004126 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4127 // then handle it as such.
4128 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004129 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4130 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4131 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4132
4133 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4134 // braces instead of the original commas.
4135 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004136 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4137 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004138 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4139 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004140 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004141 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004142 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004143 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4144 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004145 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004146 }
4147}
4148
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004149Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004150 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004151 MultiExprArg Val,
4152 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004153 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4154 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004155 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4156 Expr *expr;
4157 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4158 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4159 else
4160 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004161 return Owned(expr);
4162}
4163
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004164/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4165/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004166/// C99 6.5.15
4167QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4168 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004169 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4170 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4171 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4172
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004173 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4174 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4175 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4176 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4177 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4178 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004179
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004180 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004181 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4182 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4183 << CondTy;
4184 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004185 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004186
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004187 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004188 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4189 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004190
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004191 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4192 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004193 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4194 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4195 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004196 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004197
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004198 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4199 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004200 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4201 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004202 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004203 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004204 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004205 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004206 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004207 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004208
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004209 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004210 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004211 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4212 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4213 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4214 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4215 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4216 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4217 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004218 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4219 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004220 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004221 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004222 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4223 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004224 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004225 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004226 // promote the null to a pointer.
4227 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004228 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004229 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004230 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004231 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004232 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004233 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004234 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004235
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004236 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4237 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4238 QuestionLoc);
4239 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4240 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004241
4242
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004243 // Handle block pointer types.
4244 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4245 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4246 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4247 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004248 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4249 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004250 return destType;
4251 }
4252 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004253 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004254 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004255 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004256 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4257 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4258 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004259 return LHSTy;
4260 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004261 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004262 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4263 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004264
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004265 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4266 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004267 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004268 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004269 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4270 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4271 // to get a consistent AST.
4272 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004273 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4274 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004275 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004276 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004277 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004278 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4279 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004280 return LHSTy;
4281 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004282
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004283 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4284 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4285 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004286 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4287 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004288
4289 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4290 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4291 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004292 QualType destPointee
4293 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004294 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004295 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4296 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4297 // Promote to void*.
4298 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004299 return destType;
4300 }
4301 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004302 QualType destPointee
4303 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004304 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004305 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004306 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004307 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004308 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004309 return destType;
4310 }
4311
4312 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4313 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4314 return LHSTy;
4315 }
4316 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4317 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4318 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4319 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4320 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4321 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4322 // to get a consistent AST.
4323 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004324 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4325 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004326 return incompatTy;
4327 }
4328 // The pointer types are compatible.
4329 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4330 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4331 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4332 // type.
4333 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4334 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004335 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4336 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004337 return LHSTy;
4338 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004339
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004340 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4341 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4342 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4343 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004344 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004345 return RHSTy;
4346 }
4347 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4348 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4349 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004350 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004351 return LHSTy;
4352 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004353
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004354 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004355 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4356 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004357 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004358}
4359
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004360/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4361/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4362QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4363 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4364 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4365 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004366
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004367 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4368 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4369 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4370 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4371 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4372 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4373 return LHSTy;
4374 }
4375 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4376 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4377 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 return RHSTy;
4379 }
4380 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4381 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4382 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4383 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4384 return LHSTy;
4385 }
4386 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4387 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4388 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4389 return RHSTy;
4390 }
4391 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4392 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4393 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4394 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4395 return LHSTy;
4396 }
4397 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4398 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4399 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4400 return RHSTy;
4401 }
4402 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4403 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004404
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004405 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4406 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4407 return LHSTy;
4408 }
4409 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4410 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4411 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004412
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004413 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4414 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4415 // type. This allows
4416 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4417 // where B is a subclass of A.
4418 //
4419 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4420 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4421 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4422 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004423
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004424 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4425 // It could return the composite type.
4426 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4427 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4428 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4429 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4430 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4431 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4432 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4433 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4434 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4435 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4436 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4437 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4438 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4439 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004440 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004441 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4442 ;
4443 else {
4444 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4445 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4446 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4447 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4448 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4449 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4450 return incompatTy;
4451 }
4452 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4453 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4454 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4455 return compositeType;
4456 }
4457 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4458 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4459 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4460 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4461 QualType destPointee
4462 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4463 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4464 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4465 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4466 // Promote to void*.
4467 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4468 return destType;
4469 }
4470 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4471 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4472 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4473 QualType destPointee
4474 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4475 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4476 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4477 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4478 // Promote to void*.
4479 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4480 return destType;
4481 }
4482 return QualType();
4483}
4484
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004485/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004486/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004487Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4488 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4489 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4490 ExprArg RHS) {
4491 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4492 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004493
4494 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4495 // was the condition.
4496 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4497 if (isLHSNull)
4498 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004499
4500 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004501 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004502 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004503 return ExprError();
4504
4505 Cond.release();
4506 LHS.release();
4507 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004508 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004509 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004510 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004511}
4512
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004513// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004514// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004515// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4516// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4517// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004518Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004519Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004520 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004521
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004522 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4523 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4524 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4525 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4526 return Compatible;
4527 }
4528
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004529 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004530 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4531 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004532
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004533 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004534 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4535 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004536
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004537 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538
4539 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4540 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4541 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004542 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004543 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004544 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004545
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004546 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4547 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004548 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004549 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004550 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004551 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004553 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004554 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4555 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004556 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004557
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004558 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004559 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004560 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004561
4562 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004563 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4564 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004565 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004566 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004567 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004568 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4569 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4570 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4571 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4572 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4573 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004574 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004575 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004576 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004577 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004578
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004579 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004580 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004581 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004582 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004583
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004584 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4585 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4586 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4587 // warning can be disabled.
4588 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4589 return ConvTy;
4590 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4591 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004592
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004593 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4594 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4595 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4596 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4597 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4598 do {
4599 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4600 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004601
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004602 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4603 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4604 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004605
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004606 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004607 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004608 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004609
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004610 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004611 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004612 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004613 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004614}
4615
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004616/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4617/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4618/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4619// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004620Sema::AssignConvertType
4621Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004622 QualType rhsType) {
4623 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004624
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004625 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004626 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4627 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004628
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004629 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4630 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4631 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004633 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004634
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004635 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004636 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004637 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004639 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4640 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4641 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4642 }
4643 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004644 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004645 return ConvTy;
4646}
4647
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004648/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4649/// for assignment compatibility.
4650Sema::AssignConvertType
4651Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004652 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4653 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004654 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4655 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004656 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004657 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004658 }
4659 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4660 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004661 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4662 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004663 return IncompatiblePointer;
4664 return Compatible;
4665 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004666 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004667 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004668 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004669 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4670 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4671 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4672 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4673 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4674 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004675
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004676 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4677 return Compatible;
4678 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4679 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004680 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004681}
4682
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004683/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4684/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004685/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4686///
4687/// int a, *pint;
4688/// short *pshort;
4689/// struct foo *pfoo;
4690///
4691/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4692/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4693/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4694/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4695///
4696/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004697/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004698///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004699Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004700Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004701 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4702 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004703 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4704 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004705
4706 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004707 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004708
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004709 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4710 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4711 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4712 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4713 return Compatible;
4714 }
4715
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004716 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4717 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4718 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4719 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4720 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4721 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4722 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004723 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004724 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004725 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004726 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004727 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004728 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4729 // to the same ExtVector type.
4730 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4731 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4732 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004733 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004734 return Compatible;
4735 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004736
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004737 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004738 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004739 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004740 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004741 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4742 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004743 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004744 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004745 }
4746 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004747 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004748
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004749 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4750 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004751 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004752
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004753 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004754 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004755 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004756
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004757 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004758 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004759
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004760 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004761 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004762 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4763 return Compatible;
4764 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004765 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004766 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4767 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004768 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004769
4770 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004771 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004772 return Compatible;
4773 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004774 return Incompatible;
4775 }
4776
4777 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4778 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004779 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004780
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004781 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004782 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004783 return Compatible;
4784
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004785 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4786 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004787
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004788 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004789 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004790 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004791 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004792 return Incompatible;
4793 }
4794
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004795 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4796 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4797 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004798
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004799 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004800 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004801 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4802 return Compatible;
4803 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004804 }
4805 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004806 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004807 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004808 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004809 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4810 return Compatible;
4811 }
4812 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4813 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4814 return Compatible;
4815 return Incompatible;
4816 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004817 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004818 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004819 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4820 return Compatible;
4821
4822 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004823 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004824
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004825 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004826 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004827
4828 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004829 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004830 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004831 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004832 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004833 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4834 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4835 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4836 return Compatible;
4837
4838 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4839 return PointerToInt;
4840
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004841 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004842 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004843 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4844 return Compatible;
4845 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004846 }
4847 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004848 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004849 return Compatible;
4850 return Incompatible;
4851 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004852
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004853 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004854 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004855 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004856 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004857 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004858}
4859
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004860/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4861/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004862static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004863 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4864 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4865 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004866 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004867 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004868 SourceLocation());
4869 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4870 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4871
4872 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4873 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004874 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004875 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004876 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004877}
4878
4879Sema::AssignConvertType
4880Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4881 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4882
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004883 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004884 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4885 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004886 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004887 return Incompatible;
4888
4889 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4890 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4891 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4892 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004893 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4894 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004895 it != itend; ++it) {
4896 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4897 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4898 // 1) void pointer
4899 // 2) null pointer constant
4900 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004901 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004902 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004903 InitField = *it;
4904 break;
4905 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004906
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004907 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004908 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004909 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004910 InitField = *it;
4911 break;
4912 }
4913 }
4914
4915 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4916 == Compatible) {
4917 InitField = *it;
4918 break;
4919 }
4920 }
4921
4922 if (!InitField)
4923 return Incompatible;
4924
4925 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4926 return Compatible;
4927}
4928
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004929Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004930Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004931 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4932 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4933 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4934 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4935 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004936 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004937 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004938 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004939 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004940 }
4941
4942 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4943 // structures.
4944 }
4945
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004946 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4947 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004948 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4949 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004950 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004951 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004952 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004953 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004954 return Compatible;
4955 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004956
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004957 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004958 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004959 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004960 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004961 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004962 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004963 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004964 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004965
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004966 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4967 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004968
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004969 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4970 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004971 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4972 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4973 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4974 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004975 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004976 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004977 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004978 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004979}
4980
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004981QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004982 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004983 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004984 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004985 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004986}
4987
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004988QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004989 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004990 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004991 QualType lhsType =
4992 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4993 QualType rhsType =
4994 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004995
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004996 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004997 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004998 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004999
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005000 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5001 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005002 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5003 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005004 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5005 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005006 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005007 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005008 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5009 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5010 return lhsType;
5011 }
5012
5013 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5014 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005015 }
5016 }
5017 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005018
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005019 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5020 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5021 bool swapped = false;
5022 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5023 swapped = true;
5024 std::swap(rex, lex);
5025 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5026 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005027
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005028 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005029 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005030 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005031 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005032 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005033 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005034 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5035 return lhsType;
5036 }
5037 }
5038 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5039 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5040 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005041 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005042 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5043 return lhsType;
5044 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005045 }
5046 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005047
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005048 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005049 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005050 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005051 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005052 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005053}
5054
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005055QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5056 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005057 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005058 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005059
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005060 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005061
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005062 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5063 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5064 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005065
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005066 // Check for division by zero.
5067 if (isDiv &&
5068 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005069 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005070 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005071
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005072 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005073}
5074
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005075QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005076 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005077 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005078 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5079 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005080 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5081 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5082 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005083
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005084 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005085
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005086 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5087 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005088
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005089 // Check for remainder by zero.
5090 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005091 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5092 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005093
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005094 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005095}
5096
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005097QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005098 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005099 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5100 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5101 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5102 return compType;
5103 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005104
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005105 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005106
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005107 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005108 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5109 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5110 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005111 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005112 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005113
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005114 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5115 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005116 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005117 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5118
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005119 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005120
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005121 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005122 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005123
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005124 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5125 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005126 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5127 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005128 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005129 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005130 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005131
5132 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5133 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5134 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005135 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005136 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5137 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5138 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5139 return QualType();
5140 }
5141
5142 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5143 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5144 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005145 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005146 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005147 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005148 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005149 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5150 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005151 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5152 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005153 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005154 return QualType();
5155 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005156 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005157 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005158 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5159 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5160 return QualType();
5161 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005162
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005163 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005164 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5165 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5166 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5167 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5168 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005169 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005170 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5171 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005172 return PExp->getType();
5173 }
5174 }
5175
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005176 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005177}
5178
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005179// C99 6.5.6
5180QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005181 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5182 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5183 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5184 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5185 return compType;
5186 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005187
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005188 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005189
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005190 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005191
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005192 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005193 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5194 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005195 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005196 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005197 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005198
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005199 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005200 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005201 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005202
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005203 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005204
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005205 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5206 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5207 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5208 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5209 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5210 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5211 return QualType();
5212 }
5213
5214 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5215 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5216 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5217 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5218 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005219 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005220 return QualType();
5221 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005222
5223 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5224 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5225 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005226 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005227 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005228 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005229 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005230 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005231
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005232 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005233 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005234 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5235 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5236 return QualType();
5237 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005238
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005239 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005240 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5241 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5242 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5243 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5244 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5245 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005246 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005247 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5248
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005249 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005250 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005251 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005252
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005253 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005254 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005255 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005256
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005257 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5258 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5259 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5260 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5261 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5262 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5263 return QualType();
5264 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005265
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005266 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5267 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5268 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5269 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005270 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005271 return QualType();
5272 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005273
5274 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5275 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5276 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5277 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5278 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005279 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5280 << rex->getSourceRange()
5281 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005282 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005283
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005284 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5285 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5286 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5287 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5288 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5289 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5290 return QualType();
5291 }
5292 } else {
5293 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5294 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5295 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5296 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5297 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5298 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5299 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5300 return QualType();
5301 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005302 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005303
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005304 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5305 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5306 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5307 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5308 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005309 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005310 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005311
5312 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005313 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5314 }
5315 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005316
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005317 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005318}
5319
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005320// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005321QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005322 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005323 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005324 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5325 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005326 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005327
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005328 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5329 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5330 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5331
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005332 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5333 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005334 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5335 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5336 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5337 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5338 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005339 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005340 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005341 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005342
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005343 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005344
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005345 // Sanity-check shift operands
5346 llvm::APSInt Right;
5347 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005348 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5349 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005350 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005351 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5352 else {
5353 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5354 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5355 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5356 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5357 }
5358 }
5359
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005360 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005361 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005362}
5363
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005364static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5365 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5366 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5367 return true;
5368 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5369 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5370 }
5371 return false;
5372}
5373
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005374// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005375QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005376 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5377 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5378
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005379 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005380 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005381 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005382
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005383 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5384 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005385
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005386 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5387 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005388 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5389 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5390 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005391 //
5392 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5393 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5394 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5395 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5396 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5397 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005398 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5399 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005400 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005401 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005402 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005403 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005404 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5405 << 0 // self-
5406 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5407 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5408 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5409 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5410 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5411 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5412 // what is it always going to eval to?
5413 char always_evals_to;
5414 switch(Opc) {
5415 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5416 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5417 break;
5418 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5419 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5420 break;
5421 default:
5422 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5423 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5424 break;
5425 }
5426 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5427 << 1 // array
5428 << always_evals_to);
5429 }
5430 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005431 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005432
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005433 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5434 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5435 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5436 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005437
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005438 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5439 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005440 Expr *literalString = 0;
5441 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005442 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005443 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005444 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005445 literalString = lex;
5446 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005447 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5448 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005449 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005450 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005451 literalString = rex;
5452 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5453 }
5454
5455 if (literalString) {
5456 std::string resultComparison;
5457 switch (Opc) {
5458 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5459 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5460 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5461 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5462 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5463 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5464 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5465 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005466
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005467 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5468 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5469 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005470 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005471 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005472 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005473
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005474 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5475 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5476 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5477 else {
5478 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5479 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5480 }
5481
5482 lType = lex->getType();
5483 rType = rex->getType();
5484
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005485 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005486 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005487
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005488 if (isRelational) {
5489 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005490 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005491 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005492 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005493 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005494 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005495
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005496 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005497 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005498 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005499
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005500 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005501 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005502 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005503 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005504
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005505 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5506 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005507 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005508 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005509 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005510 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005511 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005512
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005513 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005514 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5515 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005516 if (!isRelational &&
5517 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5518 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5519 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005520 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5521 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005522 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5523 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005524 Diag(Loc,
5525 isSFINAEContext()?
5526 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5527 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005528 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005529
5530 if (isSFINAEContext())
5531 return QualType();
5532
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005533 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5534 return ResultTy;
5535 }
5536 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005537 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5538 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5539 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5540 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5541 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5542 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005543 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005544 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005545 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005546 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005547 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005548 if (T.isNull()) {
5549 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5550 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5551 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005552 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005553 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005554 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005555 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005556 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005557 }
5558
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005559 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5560 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005561 return ResultTy;
5562 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005563 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5564 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5565 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5566 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5567 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5568 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5569 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5570 }
5571 } else if (!isRelational &&
5572 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5573 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5574 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5575 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5576 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5577 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5578 }
5579 } else {
5580 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005581 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005582 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005583 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005584 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005585 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005586 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005587 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005588
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005589 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005590 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005591 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005592 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005593 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5594 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005595 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005596 return ResultTy;
5597 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005598 if (LHSIsNull &&
5599 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5600 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005601 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005602 return ResultTy;
5603 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005604
5605 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005606 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005607 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5608 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005609 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5610 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5611 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5612 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5613 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5614 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5615 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5616 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005617 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005618 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005619 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005620 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005621 if (T.isNull()) {
5622 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005623 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005624 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005625 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005626 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005627 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005628 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005629 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005630 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005631
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005632 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5633 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005634 return ResultTy;
5635 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005636
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005637 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005638 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5639 return ResultTy;
5640 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005641
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005642 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005643 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005644 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5645 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005646
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005647 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005648 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005649 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005650 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005651 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005652 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005653 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005654 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005655 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005656 if (!isRelational
5657 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5658 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005659 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005660 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005661 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005662 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005663 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5664 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5665 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005666 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005667 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005668 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005669 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005670
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005671 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005672 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005673 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5674 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005675 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005676 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005677 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005678 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005679
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005680 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5681 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005682 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005683 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005684 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005685 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005686 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005687 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005688 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005689 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005690 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5691 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005692 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005693 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005694 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005695 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005696 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5697 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005698 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005699 bool isError = false;
5700 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5701 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5702 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005703 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005704 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005705 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005706 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5707 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5708 isError = true;
5709 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005710 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005711
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005712 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005713 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005714 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005715 if (isError)
5716 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005717 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005718
5719 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5720 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005721 else
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005722 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005723 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005724 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005725
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005726 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005727 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5728 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005729 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005730 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005731 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005732 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5733 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005734 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005735 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005736 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005737 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005738}
5739
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005740/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005741/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005742/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5743/// types.
5744QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005745 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005746 bool isRelational) {
5747 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5748 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005749 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005750 if (vType.isNull())
5751 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005752
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005753 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5754 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005755
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005756 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5757 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5758 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005759 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005760 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5761 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5762 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005763 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5764 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5765 << 0 // self-
5766 << 2 // "a constant"
5767 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005768 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005769
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005770 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005771 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5772 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005773 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005774 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005775
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005776 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5777 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5778 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005779 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005780 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005781
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005782 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005783 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005784 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005785 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005786 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005787 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5788
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005789 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005790 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005791 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5792}
5793
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005794inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005795 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005796 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5797 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5798 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5799 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5800
5801 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5802 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005803
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005804 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005805
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005806 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005807 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005808 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005809}
5810
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005811inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005812 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5813
5814 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5815 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5816 // is a constant.
5817 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005818 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005819 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005820 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5821 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5822 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5823 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5824 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5825 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5826 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5827 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5828 << rex->getSourceRange()
5829 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5830 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&" : "|");
5831 }
5832 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005833
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005834 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5835 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5836 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005837
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005838 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5839 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005840
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005841 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005842 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005843
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005844 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5845 // non-overloadable operands.
5846
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005847 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5848 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005849 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5850 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5851 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005852 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005853
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005854 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5855 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5856 // The result is a bool.
5857 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005858}
5859
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005860/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5861/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5862/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5863///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005864static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005865 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5866 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5867 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5868 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005869 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005870 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5871 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5872 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5873 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005874 }
5875 }
5876 return false;
5877}
5878
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005879/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5880/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5881static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005882 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005883 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005884 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005885 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5886 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005887 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5888 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005889
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005890 unsigned Diag = 0;
5891 bool NeedType = false;
5892 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005893 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005894 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005895 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5896 NeedType = true;
5897 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005898 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005899 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5900 NeedType = true;
5901 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005902 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005903 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5904 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005905 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5906 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005907 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005908 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5909 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005910 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5911 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005912 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5913 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005914 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005915 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005916 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005917 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005918 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5919 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005920 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005921 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5922 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005923 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5924 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5925 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005926 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5927 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5928 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005929 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5930 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5931 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005932 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005933
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005934 SourceRange Assign;
5935 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5936 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005937 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005938 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005939 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005940 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005941 return true;
5942}
5943
5944
5945
5946// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005947QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5948 SourceLocation Loc,
5949 QualType CompoundType) {
5950 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5951 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005952 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005953
5954 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5955 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005956 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005957 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005958 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005959 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005960 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5961 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5962 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5963 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5964 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5965 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5966 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5967 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5968 }
5969 }
5970
5971 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005972 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5973 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5974 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005975 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005976 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005977 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005978 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005979
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005980 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5981 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5982 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005983 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005984 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5985 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5986 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5987 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5988 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005989 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005990 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005991 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5992 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5993 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005994 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5995 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005996 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5997 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5998 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005999 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006000 }
6001 } else {
6002 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006003 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006004 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006005
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006006 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006007 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006008 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006009
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006010
6011 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6012 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6013 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6014 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6015 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6016 // check.
6017 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
6018 if (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref &&
6019 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6020 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6021 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6022 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6023 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6024 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6025 }
6026
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006027 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6028 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006029 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006030 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6031 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006032 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006033 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006034 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006035}
6036
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006037// C99 6.5.17
6038QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006039 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6040
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006041 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006042 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6043 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6044 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006045
6046 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6047 // incomplete in C++).
6048
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006049 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006050}
6051
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006052/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6053/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006054QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006055 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006056 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6057 return Context.DependentTy;
6058
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006059 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6060 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006061
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006062 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6063 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6064 if (!isInc) {
6065 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6066 return QualType();
6067 }
6068 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6069 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6070 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006071 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006072 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6073 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006074
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006075 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006076 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006077 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6078 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6079 << Op->getSourceRange();
6080 return QualType();
6081 }
6082
6083 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006084 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006085 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006086 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6087 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6088 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6089 return QualType();
6090 }
6091
6092 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006093 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006094 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006095 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006096 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006097 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006098 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006099 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006100 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006101 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6102 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6103 return QualType();
6104 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006105 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006106 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6107 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006108 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006109 } else {
6110 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006111 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006112 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006113 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006114 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006115 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006116 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006117 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006118 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6119 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6120 // operand.
6121 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6122 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006123}
6124
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006125/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006126/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006127/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6128/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6129/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6130/// - &(x) => x
6131/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6132/// - &s.xx => s
6133/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6134/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6135/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6136/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006137static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006138 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006139 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006140 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006141 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006142 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6143 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6144 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006145 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006146 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006147 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006148 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006149 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006150 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6151 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006152 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6153 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6154 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6155 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6156 }
6157 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006158 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006159 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6160 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006161
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006162 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006163 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6164 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6165 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6166 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6167 default:
6168 return 0;
6169 }
6170 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006171 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006172 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006173 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006174 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6175 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006176 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006177 default:
6178 return 0;
6179 }
6180}
6181
6182/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006183/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006184/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006185/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006186/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006187/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006188/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006189QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006190 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6191 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6192
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006193 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6194 return Context.DependentTy;
6195
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006196 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6197 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6198 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6199 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6200 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6201 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6202 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6203 }
6204 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6205 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6206 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006207 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006208 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006209
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006210 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6211 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6212 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6213 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6214 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6215 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6216 // branch of the if, below.
6217 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6218 << dcl;
6219 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6220
6221 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6222 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6223 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6224 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006225 }
6226
6227 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006228 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6229 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6230 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6231 if (isSFINAEContext())
6232 return QualType();
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006233 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006234 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006235 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006236 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006237 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006238 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006239 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006240 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6241 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006242 return QualType();
6243 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006244 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006245 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6246 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6247 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006248 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006249 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006250 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006251 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006252 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006253 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006254 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6255 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6256 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6257 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6258 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006259 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6260 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006261 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6262 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006263 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6264 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006265 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006266 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006267 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6268 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006269 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006270 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6271 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006272 return QualType();
6273 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006274 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006275 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006276 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006277 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006278 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6279 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006280 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006281 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006282 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6283 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006284 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006285 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6286 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6287 return QualType();
6288 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006289
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006290 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6291 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006292 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006293 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006294 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006295 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006296 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006297 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6298 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006299 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6300 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6301 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006302 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006303 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006304
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006305 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6306 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6307 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6308 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6309 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6310 }
6311
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006312 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006313 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006314}
6315
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006316/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006317QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006318 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6319 return Context.DependentTy;
6320
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006321 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006322 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6323 QualType Result;
6324
6325 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6326 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6327 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6328 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6329 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6330 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6331 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6332 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6333 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006334
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006335 if (Result.isNull()) {
6336 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6337 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6338 return QualType();
6339 }
6340
6341 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006342}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006343
6344static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6345 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6346 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6347 switch (Kind) {
6348 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006349 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6350 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006351 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6352 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6353 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6354 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6355 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6356 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6357 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6358 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6359 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6360 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6361 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6362 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6363 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6364 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6365 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6366 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6367 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6368 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6369 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6370 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6371 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6372 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6373 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6374 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6375 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6376 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6377 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6378 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6379 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6380 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6381 }
6382 return Opc;
6383}
6384
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006385static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6386 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6387 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6388 switch (Kind) {
6389 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6390 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6391 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6392 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6393 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6394 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6395 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6396 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6397 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006398 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6399 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006400 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006401 }
6402 return Opc;
6403}
6404
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006405/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6406/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6407/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006408Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6409 unsigned Op,
6410 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006411 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006412 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006413 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6414 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6415 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006416
6417 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006418 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6419 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6420 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006421 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6422 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6423 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6424 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6425 break;
6426 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006427 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006428 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6429 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006430 break;
6431 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6432 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6433 break;
6434 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6435 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6436 break;
6437 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6438 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6439 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006440 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006441 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6442 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6443 break;
6444 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6445 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6446 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6447 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006448 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006449 break;
6450 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6451 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006452 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006453 break;
6454 case BinaryOperator::And:
6455 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6456 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6457 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6458 break;
6459 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6460 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006461 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006462 break;
6463 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6464 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006465 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6466 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006467 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6468 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6469 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006470 break;
6471 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006472 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6473 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6474 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6475 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006476 break;
6477 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006478 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6479 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6480 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006481 break;
6482 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006483 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6484 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6485 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006486 break;
6487 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6488 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006489 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6490 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6491 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6492 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006493 break;
6494 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6495 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6496 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006497 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6498 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6499 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6500 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006501 break;
6502 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6503 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6504 break;
6505 }
6506 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006507 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006508 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006509 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6510 else
6511 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006512 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6513 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006514}
6515
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006516/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6517/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006518static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6519 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006520 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6521 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6522 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006523 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006524 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6525
6526 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6527 return;
6528
6529 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6530 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6531 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006532 return;
6533 }
6534
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006535 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6536 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006537 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006538
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006539 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006540 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006541
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006542 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6543 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6544 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6545 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006546 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006547 return;
6548 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006549
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006550 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006551 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6552 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006553}
6554
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006555/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6556/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6557/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6558/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006559static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6560 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006561 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6562 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6563 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6564 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006565 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006566 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006567 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6568
6569 // Subs are not binary operators.
6570 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6571 return;
6572
6573 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6574 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006575 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6576 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006577 return;
6578
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006579 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006580 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006581 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006582 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6583 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006584 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006585 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006586 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6587 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6588 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6589 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006590 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006591 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006592 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006593 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6594 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006595 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006596 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006597 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6598 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6599 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6600 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006601}
6602
6603/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6604/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6605/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6606static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6607 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006608 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006609 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6610}
6611
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006612// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006613Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6614 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6615 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006616 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006617 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006618
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006619 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6620 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006621
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006622 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6623 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6624
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006625 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6626}
6627
6628Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6629 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6630 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006631 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006632 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006633 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6634 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6635 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6636 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6637 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006638 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006639 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006640 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6641 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6642 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006643
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006644 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6645 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006646 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006647 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006648
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006649 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006650 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006651}
6652
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006653Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006654 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006655 ExprArg InputArg) {
6656 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006657
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006658 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006659 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006660 QualType resultType;
6661 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006662 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6663 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6664 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006665
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006666 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6667 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006668 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6669 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006670 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006671 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006672 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6673 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6674 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006675 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006676 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006677 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006678 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006679 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006680 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006681 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006682 break;
6683 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6684 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006685 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6686 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006687 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6688 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006689 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6690 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006691 break;
6692 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6693 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6694 break;
6695 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6696 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6697 resultType->isPointerType())
6698 break;
6699
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006700 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6701 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006702 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006703 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6704 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006705 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6706 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006707 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6708 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6709 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006710 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006711 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006712 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006713 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6714 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006715 break;
6716 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006717 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006718 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006719 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006720 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6721 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006722 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006723 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6724 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006725 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006726 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6727 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006728 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006729 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006730 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006731 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006732 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006733 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006734 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006735 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006736 }
6737 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006738 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006739
6740 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006741 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006742}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006743
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006744Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6745 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6746 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006747 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006748 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6749 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006750 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6751 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6752 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6753 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006754 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006755 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006756 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6757 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6758 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006759
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006760 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6761 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006762
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006763 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6764}
6765
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006766// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6767Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6768 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6769 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6770}
6771
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006772/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006773Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6774 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6775 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006776 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006777 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006778
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006779 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6780 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006781 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006782 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006783
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006784 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006785 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6786 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006787}
6788
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006789Sema::OwningExprResult
6790Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6791 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6792 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006793 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6794 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6795
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006796 bool isFileScope
6797 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006798 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006799 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006800
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006801 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6802 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6803 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006804
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006805 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6806 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6807 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006808
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006809 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6810 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6811 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6812 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6813 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006814
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006815 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006816 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006817 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006818
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006819 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6820 // expressions are not lvalues.
6821
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006822 substmt.release();
6823 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006824}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006825
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006826Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6827 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006828 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6829 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006830 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6831 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006832 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006833 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006834
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006835 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6836 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6837 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006838 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006839 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6840 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6841
6842 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6843 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6844 if (!Dependent
6845 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6846 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6847 << TypeRange))
6848 return ExprError();
6849
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006850 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6851 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006852 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6853 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006854 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006855 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6856 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006857
6858 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6859 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6860 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6861 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6862 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6863 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6864 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6865 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6866 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6867 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6868 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6869 if(!AT)
6870 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6871 << CurrentType);
6872 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6873 } else
6874 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6875
6876 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6877 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6878 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6879 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6880 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6881 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6882 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6883 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6884
6885 // Record this array index.
6886 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6887 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6888 continue;
6889 }
6890
6891 // Offset of a field.
6892 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6893 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6894 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6895 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6896 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6897 continue;
6898 }
6899
6900 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6901 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6902 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6903 return ExprError();
6904
6905 // Look for the designated field.
6906 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6907 if (!RC)
6908 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6909 << CurrentType);
6910 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6911
6912 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6913 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6914 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6915 // (clause 9).
6916 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6917 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6918 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6919 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6920 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6921 << CurrentType))
6922 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6923 }
6924
6925 // Look for the field.
6926 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6927 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6928 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6929 if (!MemberDecl)
6930 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6931 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6932 OC.LocEnd));
6933
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006934 // C99 7.17p3:
6935 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6936 //
6937 // We diagnose this as an error.
6938 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6939 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6940 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6941 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6942 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6943 return ExprError();
6944 }
6945
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006946 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6947 // the base class indirections.
6948 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6949 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6950 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6951 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6952 Paths)) {
6953 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6954 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6955 B != BEnd; ++B)
6956 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6957 }
6958
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006959 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006960 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006961 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6962 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6963 unsigned n = Path.size();
6964 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6965 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6966 } else {
6967 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6968 }
6969 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6970 }
6971
6972 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6973 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6974 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6975}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006976
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006977Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6978 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6979 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6980 TypeTy *argty,
6981 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6982 unsigned NumComponents,
6983 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6984
6985 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6986 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6987 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6988 return ExprError();
6989
6990 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6991 if (!ArgTInfo)
6992 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6993
6994 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6995 RPLoc);
6996 }
6997
6998 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6999 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
7000
7001 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
7002
7003 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7004 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7005 // a struct/union/class.
7006 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
7007 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
7008
7009 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7010 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
7011
7012 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
7013 // the offsetof designators.
7014 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
7015 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
7016 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
7017 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
7018
7019 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7020 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
7021 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7022 // a system header!
7023 if (NumComponents != 1)
7024 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7025 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
7026
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007027 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00007028 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007029
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00007030 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
7031 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7032 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007033
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007034 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
7035 // leaks like a sieve.
7036 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7037 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7038 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7039 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7040 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007041 if (!AT)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007042 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007043 << Res->getType());
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007044
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007045 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007046
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007047 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
7048 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007049 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007050
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007051 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
7052 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007053 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007054 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007055 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00007056 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007057 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7058
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007059 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
7060 OC.LocEnd);
7061 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007062 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007063
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007064 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007065 if (!RC)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007066 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007067 << Res->getType());
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007068
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007069 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
7070 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00007071 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007072 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7073 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7074 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007075 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7076 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007077 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00007078 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007079
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00007080 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7081 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007082
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00007083 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007084 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007085 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00007086 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007087 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
7088
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007089 // C99 7.17p3:
7090 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7091 //
7092 // We diagnose this as an error.
7093 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7094 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7095 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7096 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7097 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7098 return ExprError();
7099 }
7100
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007101 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
7102 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007103 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00007104 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007105 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007106 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007107 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
7108 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007109 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
7110 // doesn't matter here.
7111 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007112 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00007113 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007114 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007115 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007116
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007117 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
7118 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007119}
7120
7121
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007122Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7123 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
7124 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007125 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
7126 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
7127 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007128
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007129 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007130
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007131 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7132 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7133 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7134 return ExprError();
7135 }
7136
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007137 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
7138 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007139}
7140
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007141Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7142 ExprArg cond,
7143 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7144 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7145 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7146 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7147 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007148
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007149 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7150
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007151 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007152 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007153 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007154 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007155 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007156 } else {
7157 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7158 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7159 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7160 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007161 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7162 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7163 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007164
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007165 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7166 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007167 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7168 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007169 }
7170
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007171 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7172 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007173 resType, RPLoc,
7174 resType->isDependentType(),
7175 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007176}
7177
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007178//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7179// Clang Extensions.
7180//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7181
7182/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007183void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007184 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7185 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7186 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007187 if (BlockScope)
7188 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7189 else
7190 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007191}
7192
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007193void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007194 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007195 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007196
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007197 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007198 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007199 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007200
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007201 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007202 QualType RetTy;
7203 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007204 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007205 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007206 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007207 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7208 } else {
7209 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007210 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007211 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007212
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007213 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007214
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007215 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7216 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7217 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007218 return;
7219 }
7220
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007221 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7222 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7223 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7224 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7225 return;
7226 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007227
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007228 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007229 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7230 // ^ * { ... }
7231 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007232 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7233 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007234
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007235 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007236 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007237 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7238 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7239 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7240 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007241 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7242 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7243 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7244 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7245 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007246 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007247 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007248
7249 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7250 // ^ fntype { ... }
7251 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7252 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7253 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7254 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7255 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7256 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7257 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007258 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007259 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007260 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007261
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007262 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7263 if (!Params.empty())
7264 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007265
7266 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007267 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007268
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007269 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007270 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7271 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7272 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7273 }
7274
7275 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7276 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007277 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007278 return;
7279
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007280 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7281 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7282
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007283 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007284 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7285 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7286
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007287 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007288 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7289 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7290 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7291
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007292 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007293 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007294 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007295}
7296
7297/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7298/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7299void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007300 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007301 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007302 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007303 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007304}
7305
7306/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7307/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007308Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7309 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007310 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7311 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7312 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007313
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007314 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007315
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007316 PopDeclContext();
7317
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007318 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007319 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7320 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007321
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007322 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007323 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007324
7325 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7326 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7327 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7328
7329 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7330 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7331
7332 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7333 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7334 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7335 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7336
7337 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7338 // preserve its sugar structure.
7339 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7340 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7341 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7342
7343 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7344 } else {
7345 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7346 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7347 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7348 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7349 FPT->isVariadic(),
7350 /*quals*/ 0,
7351 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7352 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7353 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7354 FPT->exception_begin(),
7355 Ext);
7356 }
7357
7358 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7359 } else {
7360 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7361 false, false, 0, 0,
7362 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7363 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007364
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007365 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007366 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7367 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007368 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007369
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007370 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007371 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007372 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007373
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007374 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007375
7376 bool Good = true;
7377 // Check goto/label use.
7378 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7379 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7380 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7381
7382 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7383 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7384 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7385 continue;
7386
7387 // Emit error.
7388 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7389 Good = false;
7390 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007391 if (!Good) {
7392 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007393 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007394 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007395
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007396 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007397 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7398 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7399 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007400
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007401 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7402 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007403 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007404 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007405}
7406
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007407Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7408 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7409 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007410 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007411 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7412 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007413
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007414 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007415
7416 // Get the va_list type
7417 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007418 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7419 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7420 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7421 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007422 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007423 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7424 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7425 } else {
7426 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7427 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007428 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007429 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007430 return ExprError();
7431 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007432
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007433 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7434 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007435 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7436 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007437 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007438 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007439
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007440 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007441 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007442
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007443 expr.release();
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00007444 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E,
7445 T.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007446 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007447}
7448
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007449Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007450 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7451 // pointers on the target.
7452 QualType Ty;
7453 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7454 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7455 else
7456 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7457
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007458 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007459}
7460
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007461static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007462 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007463 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7464 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007465
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007466 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7467 if (!PT)
7468 return;
7469
7470 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7471 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7472 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7473 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7474 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7475 return;
7476 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007477
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007478 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7479 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7480 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7481 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007482
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007483 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007484}
7485
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007486bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7487 SourceLocation Loc,
7488 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007489 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7490 bool *Complained) {
7491 if (Complained)
7492 *Complained = false;
7493
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007494 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7495 bool isInvalid = false;
7496 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007497 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007498
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007499 switch (ConvTy) {
7500 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7501 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007502 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007503 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7504 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007505 case IntToPointer:
7506 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7507 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007508 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007509 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007510 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7511 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007512 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7513 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7514 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007515 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7516 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7517 break;
7518 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007519 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7520 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7521 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7522 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7523 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7524 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7525 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7526 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7527 // C++ semantics.
7528 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7529 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7530 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007531 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7532 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007533 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007534 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007535 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007536 case IntToBlockPointer:
7537 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7538 break;
7539 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007540 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007541 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007542 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007543 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007544 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7545 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7546 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007547 case IncompatibleVectors:
7548 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7549 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007550 case Incompatible:
7551 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7552 isInvalid = true;
7553 break;
7554 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007555
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007556 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7557 switch (Action) {
7558 case AA_Assigning:
7559 case AA_Initializing:
7560 // The destination type comes first.
7561 FirstType = DstType;
7562 SecondType = SrcType;
7563 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007564
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007565 case AA_Returning:
7566 case AA_Passing:
7567 case AA_Converting:
7568 case AA_Sending:
7569 case AA_Casting:
7570 // The source type comes first.
7571 FirstType = SrcType;
7572 SecondType = DstType;
7573 break;
7574 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007575
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007576 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007577 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007578 if (Complained)
7579 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007580 return isInvalid;
7581}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007582
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007583bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007584 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7585 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7586 if (Result)
7587 *Result = ICEResult;
7588 return false;
7589 }
7590
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007591 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7592
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007593 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007594 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7595 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7596
7597 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7598 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7599 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7600 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7601 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7602 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7603 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007604
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007605 return true;
7606 }
7607
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007608 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7609 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007610
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007611 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7612 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7613 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007614
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007615 if (Result)
7616 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7617 return false;
7618}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007619
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007620void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007621Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007622 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7623 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007624}
7625
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007626void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007627Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7628 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7629 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7630 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007631
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007632 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7633 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7634 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7635 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7636 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007637 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007638 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7639 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7640 I != IEnd; ++I)
7641 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7642 }
7643
7644 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7645 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7646 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7647 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7648 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7649 I != IEnd; ++I)
7650 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7651 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007652 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007653
7654 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7655 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7656 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7657 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007658 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007659 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7660 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7661 ExprTemporaries.end());
7662
7663 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7664 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007665}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007666
7667/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7668///
7669/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7670/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7671/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7672/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7673///
7674/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7675///
7676/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7677void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7678 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007679
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007680 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007681 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007682
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007683 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7684 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7685 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7686 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007687 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007688 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007689 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007690 return;
7691 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007692
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007693 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7694 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007695
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007696 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7697 // an instantiation.
7698 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7699 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007700
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007701 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007702 case Unevaluated:
7703 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7704 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007705
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007706 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7707 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7708 // "used"; handle this below.
7709 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007710
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007711 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7712 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7713 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7714 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007715 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007716 return;
7717 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007718
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007719 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007720 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007721 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007722 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007723 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007724 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007725 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007726 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007727 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007728 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7729 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007730
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007731 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007732 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007733 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007734 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007735 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7736 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007737 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7738 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7739 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007740 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007741 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007742 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7743 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007744 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007745 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007746 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007747 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007748 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007749 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7750 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7751 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7752 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7753 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007754 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007755 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007756 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007757 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007758 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7759 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7760 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007761 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007762 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007763 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7764 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007765
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007766 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7767 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7768 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7769 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7770 Loc));
7771 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007772 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007773 Loc));
7774 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007775 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007776
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007777 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007778 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007779
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007780 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007781 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007782
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007783 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007784 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007785 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007786 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7787 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7788 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7789 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7790 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7791 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7792 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7793 }
7794 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007795
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007796 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007797
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007798 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007799 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007800 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007801}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007802
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007803namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007804 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007805 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007806 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007807 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7808 Sema &S;
7809 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007810
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007811 public:
7812 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007813
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007814 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007815
7816 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7817 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007818 };
7819}
7820
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007821bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7822 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007823 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7824 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7825 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007826
7827 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007828}
7829
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007830bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007831 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7832 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7833 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007834 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7835 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007836 }
7837
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007838 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007839}
7840
7841void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7842 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007843 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007844}
7845
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007846/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7847/// of the program being compiled.
7848///
7849/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007850/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007851/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7852/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7853/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7854/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007855/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007856/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007857///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007858/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7859/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7860/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7861/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007862bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007863 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7864 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7865 case Unevaluated:
7866 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7867 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007868
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007869 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7870 Diag(Loc, PD);
7871 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007872
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007873 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7874 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7875 break;
7876 }
7877
7878 return false;
7879}
7880
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007881bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7882 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7883 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7884 return false;
7885
7886 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7887 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7888 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7889 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007890
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007891 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007892 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007893 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7894 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007895 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007896 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7897 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7898 return true;
7899
7900 return false;
7901}
7902
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007903// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7904// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7905void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7906 SourceLocation Loc;
7907
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007908 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7909
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007910 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7911 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7912 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7913 return;
7914
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007915 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7916 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7917 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7918 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7919
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007920 // self = [<foo> init...]
7921 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7922 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7923 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7924
7925 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7926 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7927 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7928 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7929 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007930
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007931 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7932 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7933 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7934 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7935 return;
7936
7937 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7938 } else {
7939 // Not an assignment.
7940 return;
7941 }
7942
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007943 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007944 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007945
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007946 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007947 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007948 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007949 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7950 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7951 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007952}
7953
7954bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7955 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7956
7957 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007958 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007959
7960 QualType T = E->getType();
7961
7962 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7963 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7964 return true;
7965 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7966 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7967 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7968 return true;
7969 }
7970 }
7971
7972 return false;
7973}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007974
7975Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7976 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007977 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7978 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007979 return ExprError();
7980
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007981 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007982 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007983
7984 return Owned(Sub);
7985}